xref: /openbmc/linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision d5a05299306227d73b0febba9cecedf88931c507)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224 };
225 
226 /**
227  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228  *
229  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231  *
232  * @def: the channel definition
233  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242  */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246 
247 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248 
249 	bool radar_enabled;
250 
251 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253 
254 /**
255  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266  *      for changes/removal.)
267  */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272 
273 /**
274  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275  *
276  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279  * done.
280  *
281  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285  */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292 
293 /**
294  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295  *
296  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298  *
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300  *	also implies a change in the AID.
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324  *	changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329  *	context had been assigned.
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333  *	keep alive) changed.
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342  *	status changed.
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344  */
345 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
347 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
348 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
358 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
359 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
360 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
361 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
362 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
363 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
364 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
365 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
366 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
367 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
379 
380 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381 };
382 
383 /*
384  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386  * filtering will be disabled.
387  */
388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389 
390 /**
391  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
398  */
399 enum ieee80211_event_type {
400 	RSSI_EVENT,
401 	MLME_EVENT,
402 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
403 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404 };
405 
406 /**
407  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410  */
411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414 };
415 
416 /**
417  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419  */
420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422 };
423 
424 /**
425  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430  */
431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432 	AUTH_EVENT,
433 	ASSOC_EVENT,
434 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436 };
437 
438 /**
439  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443  */
444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445 	MLME_SUCCESS,
446 	MLME_DENIED,
447 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
448 };
449 
450 /**
451  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455  */
456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459 	u16 reason;
460 };
461 
462 /**
463  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465  * @tid: the tid
466  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467  */
468 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470 	u16 tid;
471 	u16 ssn;
472 };
473 
474 /**
475  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477  * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478  * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479  * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480  * @u:union holding the fields above
481  */
482 struct ieee80211_event {
483 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484 	union {
485 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488 	} u;
489 };
490 
491 /**
492  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493  *
494  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495  *
496  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498  */
499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502 };
503 
504 /**
505  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506  *
507  * @lci: LCI subelement content
508  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509  * @lci_len: LCI data length
510  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511  */
512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513 	const u8 *lci;
514 	const u8 *civicloc;
515 	size_t lci_len;
516 	size_t civicloc_len;
517 };
518 
519 /**
520  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522  *
523  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525  */
526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527 	u32 min_interval;
528 	u32 max_interval;
529 };
530 
531 /**
532  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533  *
534  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536  *
537  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
538  * @addr: (link) address used locally
539  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
540  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
541  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
542  * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
543  *	ACK, BACK or both
544  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
545  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
546  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
547  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
548  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
549  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
550  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
551  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
552  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
553  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
554  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
555  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
556  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
557  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
558  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
559  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
560  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
561  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
562  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
563  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
564  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
565  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
566  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
567  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
568  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
569  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
570  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
571  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
572  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
573  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
574  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
575  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
576  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
577  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
578  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
579  *	the current band.
580  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
581  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
582  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
583  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
584  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
585  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
586  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
587  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
588  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
589  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
590  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
591  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
592  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
593  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
594  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
595  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
596  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
597  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
598  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
599  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
600  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
601  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
602  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
603  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
604  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
605  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
606  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
607  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
608  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
609  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
610  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
611  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
612  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
613  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
614  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
615  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
616  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
617  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
618  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
619  *	station.
620  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
621  *	responder functionality.
622  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
623  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
624  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
625  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
626  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
627  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
628  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
629  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
630  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
631  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
632  *	connected to (STA)
633  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
634  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
635  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
636  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
637  *	interval.
638  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
639  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
640  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
641  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
642  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
643  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
644  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
645  * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
646  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
647  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
648  *	for read access.
649  * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
650  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
651  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
652  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
653  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
654  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
655  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
656  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
657  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
658  *	for read access.
659  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
660  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
661  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
662  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
663  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
664  *	beamformer
665  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
666  *	beamformee
667  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
668  *	beamformer
669  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
670  *	beamformee
671  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
672  *	beamformer
673  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
674  *	beamformee
675  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
676  *	beamformer
677  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
678  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
679  *	bandwidth
680  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
681  *	beamformer
682  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
683  *	beamformee
684  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
685  *	beamformer
686  */
687 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
688 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
689 
690 	const u8 *bssid;
691 	unsigned int link_id;
692 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
693 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
694 	bool uora_exists;
695 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
696 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
697 	bool he_support;
698 	bool twt_requester;
699 	bool twt_responder;
700 	bool twt_protected;
701 	bool twt_broadcast;
702 	/* erp related data */
703 	bool use_cts_prot;
704 	bool use_short_preamble;
705 	bool use_short_slot;
706 	bool enable_beacon;
707 	u8 dtim_period;
708 	u16 beacon_int;
709 	u16 assoc_capability;
710 	u64 sync_tsf;
711 	u32 sync_device_ts;
712 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
713 	u32 basic_rates;
714 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
715 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
716 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
717 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
718 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
719 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
720 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
721 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
722 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
723 	bool qos;
724 	bool hidden_ssid;
725 	int txpower;
726 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
727 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
728 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
729 	u16 max_idle_period;
730 	bool protected_keep_alive;
731 	bool ftm_responder;
732 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
733 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
734 	bool nontransmitted;
735 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
736 	u8 bssid_index;
737 	u8 bssid_indicator;
738 	bool ema_ap;
739 	u8 profile_periodicity;
740 	struct {
741 		u32 params;
742 		u16 nss_set;
743 	} he_oper;
744 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
745 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
746 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
747 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
748 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
749 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
750 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
751 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
752 	u8 pwr_reduction;
753 	bool eht_support;
754 	u16 eht_puncturing;
755 
756 	bool csa_active;
757 	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
758 
759 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
760 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
761 
762 	bool color_change_active;
763 	u8 color_change_color;
764 
765 	bool ht_ldpc;
766 	bool vht_ldpc;
767 	bool he_ldpc;
768 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
769 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
770 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
771 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
772 	bool he_su_beamformer;
773 	bool he_su_beamformee;
774 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
775 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
776 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
777 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
778 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
779 };
780 
781 /**
782  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
783  *
784  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
785  *
786  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
787  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
788  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
789  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
790  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
791  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
792  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
793  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
794  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
795  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
796  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
797  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
798  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
799  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
800  *	station
801  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
802  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
803  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
804  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
805  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
806  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
807  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
808  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
809  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
810  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
811  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
812  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
813  *	hardware queue.
814  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
815  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
816  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
817  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
818  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
819  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
820  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
821  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
822  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
823  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
824  *	off-channel operation.
825  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
826  *	(header conversion)
827  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
828  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
829  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
830  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
831  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
832  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
833  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
834  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
835  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
836  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
837  *	queue gets full.
838  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
839  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
840  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
841  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
842  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
843  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
844  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
845  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
846  *	status to user space)
847  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
848  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
849  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
850  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
851  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
852  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
853  *	handled properly by the device.
854  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
855  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
856  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
857  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
858  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
859  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
860  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
861  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
862  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
863  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
864  *	PS-Poll responses.
865  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
866  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
867  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
868  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
869  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
870  *	monitor injection).
871  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
872  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
873  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
874  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
875  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
876  *
877  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
878  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
879  */
880 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
881 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
882 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
883 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
884 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
885 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
886 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
887 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
888 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
889 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
890 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
891 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
892 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
893 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
894 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
895 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
896 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
897 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
898 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
899 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
900 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
901 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
902 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
903 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
904 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
905 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
906 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
907 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
908 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
909 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
910 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
911 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
912 };
913 
914 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
915 
916 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
917 
918 /**
919  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
920  *
921  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
922  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
923  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
924  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
925  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
926  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
927  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
928  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
929  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
930  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
931  *	it can be sent out.
932  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
933  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
934  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
935  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
936  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
937  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
938  *	for sequence number assignment
939  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
940  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
941  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
942  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
943  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
944  *	it's intended for an MLD.
945  *
946  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
947  */
948 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
949 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
950 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
951 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
952 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
953 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
954 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
955 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
956 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
957 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
958 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
959 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
960 };
961 
962 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
963 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
964 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
965 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
966 
967 /**
968  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
969  *
970  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
971  *
972  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
973  */
974 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
975 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
976 };
977 
978 /*
979  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
980  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
981  */
982 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
983 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
984 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
985 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
986 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
987 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
988 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
989 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
990 
991 /**
992  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
993  *	Rate Control algorithm.
994  *
995  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
996  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
997  *
998  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
999  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1000  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1001  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1002  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1003  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1004  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1005  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1006  *	Greenfield mode.
1007  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1008  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1009  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1010  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1011  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1012  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1013  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1014  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1015  */
1016 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1017 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1018 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1019 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1020 
1021 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1022 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1023 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1024 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1025 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1026 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1027 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1028 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1029 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1030 };
1031 
1032 
1033 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1034 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1035 
1036 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1037 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1038 
1039 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1040 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1041 
1042 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1043 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1044 
1045 /**
1046  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1047  *
1048  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1049  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1050  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1051  *
1052  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1053  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1054  *
1055  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1056  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1057  *
1058  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1059  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1060  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1061  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1062  * information::
1063  *
1064  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1065  *
1066  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1067  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1068  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1069  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1070  * information should then contain::
1071  *
1072  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1073  *
1074  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1075  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1076  */
1077 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1078 	s8 idx;
1079 	u16 count:5,
1080 	    flags:11;
1081 } __packed;
1082 
1083 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1084 
1085 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1086 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1087 {
1088 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1089 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1090 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1091 }
1092 
1093 static inline u8
1094 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1095 {
1096 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1097 }
1098 
1099 static inline u8
1100 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1101 {
1102 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1103 }
1104 
1105 /**
1106  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1107  *
1108  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1109  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1110  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1111  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1112  *
1113  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1114  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1115  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1116  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1117  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1118  * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1119  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1120  * @control: union part for control data
1121  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1122  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1123  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1124  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1125  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1126  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1127  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1128  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1129  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1130  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1131  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1132  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1133  * @pad: padding
1134  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1135  * @status: union part for status data
1136  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1137  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1138  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1139  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1140  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1141  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1142  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1143  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1144  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1145  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1146  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1147  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1148  * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1149  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1150  * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1151  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1152  * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1153  */
1154 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1155 	/* common information */
1156 	u32 flags;
1157 	u32 band:3,
1158 	    ack_frame_id:13,
1159 	    hw_queue:4,
1160 	    tx_time_est:10;
1161 	/* 2 free bits */
1162 
1163 	union {
1164 		struct {
1165 			union {
1166 				/* rate control */
1167 				struct {
1168 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1169 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1170 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1171 					u8 use_rts:1;
1172 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1173 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1174 					u8 skip_table:1;
1175 					/* 2 bytes free */
1176 				};
1177 				/* only needed before rate control */
1178 				unsigned long jiffies;
1179 			};
1180 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1181 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1182 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1183 			u32 flags;
1184 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1185 		} control;
1186 		struct {
1187 			u64 cookie;
1188 		} ack;
1189 		struct {
1190 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1191 			s32 ack_signal;
1192 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1193 			u8 ampdu_len;
1194 			u8 antenna;
1195 			u16 tx_time;
1196 			u8 flags;
1197 			void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
1198 		} status;
1199 		struct {
1200 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1201 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1202 			u8 pad[4];
1203 
1204 			void *rate_driver_data[
1205 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1206 		};
1207 		void *driver_data[
1208 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1209 	};
1210 };
1211 
1212 static inline u16
1213 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1214 {
1215 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1216 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1217 	 */
1218 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1219 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1220 }
1221 
1222 static inline u16
1223 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1224 {
1225 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1226 }
1227 
1228 /***
1229  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1230  *
1231  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1232  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1233  *
1234  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1235  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1236  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1237  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1238  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1239  */
1240 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1241 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1242 	u8 try_count;
1243 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1244 };
1245 
1246 /**
1247  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1248  *
1249  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1250  * @info: Basic tx status information
1251  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1252  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1253  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1254  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1255  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1256  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1257  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1258  */
1259 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1260 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1261 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1262 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1263 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1264 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1265 	u8 n_rates;
1266 
1267 	struct list_head *free_list;
1268 };
1269 
1270 /**
1271  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1272  *
1273  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1274  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1275  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1276  *
1277  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1278  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1279  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1280  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1281  */
1282 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1283 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1284 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1285 	const u8 *common_ies;
1286 	size_t common_ie_len;
1287 };
1288 
1289 
1290 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1291 {
1292 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1293 }
1294 
1295 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1296 {
1297 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1298 }
1299 
1300 /**
1301  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1302  *
1303  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1304  *
1305  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1306  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1307  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1308  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1309  *
1310  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1311  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1312  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1313  */
1314 static inline void
1315 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1316 {
1317 	int i;
1318 
1319 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1320 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1321 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1322 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1323 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1324 	/* clear the rate counts */
1325 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1326 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1327 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1328 }
1329 
1330 
1331 /**
1332  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1333  *
1334  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1335  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1336  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1337  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1338  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1339  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1340  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1341  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1342  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1343  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1344  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1345  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1346  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1347  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1348  *	de-duplication by itself.
1349  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1350  *	the frame.
1351  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1352  *	the frame.
1353  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1354  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1355  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1356  *	merging.
1357  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1358  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1359  *	(including FCS) was received.
1360  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1361  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1362  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1363  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1364  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1365  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1366  *	each A-MPDU
1367  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1368  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1369  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1370  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1371  *	on this subframe
1372  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1373  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1374  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1375  *	done by the hardware
1376  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1377  *	processing it in any regular way.
1378  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1379  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1380  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1381  *	monitor interfaces.
1382  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1383  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1384  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1385  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1386  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1387  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1388  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1389  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1390  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1391  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1392  *	interleaved with other frames.
1393  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1394  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1395  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1396  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1397  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1398  *	in the skb.
1399  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1400  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1401  *	the first subframe.
1402  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1403  *	be done in the hardware.
1404  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1405  *	frame
1406  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1407  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1408  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1409  *
1410  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1411  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1412  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1413  *	 - DATA5_GI
1414  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1415  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1416  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1417  *
1418  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1419  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1420  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1421  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1422  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1423  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1424  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1425  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1426  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1427  *	hardware or driver)
1428  */
1429 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1430 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1431 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1432 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1433 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1434 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1435 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1436 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1437 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1438 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1439 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1440 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1441 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1442 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1443 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1444 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1445 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1446 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1447 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1448 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1449 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1450 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1451 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1452 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1453 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1454 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1455 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1456 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1457 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1458 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1459 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1460 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1461 };
1462 
1463 /**
1464  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1465  *
1466  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1467  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1468  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1469  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1470  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1471  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1472  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1473  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1474  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1475  */
1476 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1477 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1478 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1479 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1480 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1481 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1482 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1483 };
1484 
1485 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1486 
1487 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1488 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1489 	RX_ENC_HT,
1490 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1491 	RX_ENC_HE,
1492 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1493 };
1494 
1495 /**
1496  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1497  *
1498  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1499  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1500  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1501  *
1502  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1503  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1504  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1505  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1506  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1507  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1508  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1509  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1510  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1511  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1512  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1513  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1514  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1515  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1516  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1517  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1518  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1519  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1520  *	values were filled.
1521  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1522  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1523  * @antenna: antenna used
1524  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1525  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1526  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1527  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1528  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1529  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1530  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1531  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1532  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1533  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1534  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1535  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1536  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1537  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1538  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1539  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1540  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1541  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1542  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1543  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1544  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1545  *	@link_valid.
1546  */
1547 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1548 	u64 mactime;
1549 	union {
1550 		u64 boottime_ns;
1551 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1552 	};
1553 	u32 device_timestamp;
1554 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1555 	u32 flag;
1556 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1557 	u8 enc_flags;
1558 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1559 	union {
1560 		struct {
1561 			u8 he_ru:3;
1562 			u8 he_gi:2;
1563 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1564 		};
1565 		struct {
1566 			u8 ru:4;
1567 			u8 gi:2;
1568 		} eht;
1569 	};
1570 	u8 rate_idx;
1571 	u8 nss;
1572 	u8 rx_flags;
1573 	u8 band;
1574 	u8 antenna;
1575 	s8 signal;
1576 	u8 chains;
1577 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1578 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1579 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1580 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1581 };
1582 
1583 static inline u32
1584 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1585 {
1586 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1587 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1588 }
1589 
1590 /**
1591  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1592  *
1593  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1594  *
1595  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1596  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1597  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1598  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1599  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1600  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1601  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1602  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1603  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1604  *	for more.
1605  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1606  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1607  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1608  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1609  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1610  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1611  *	operating channel.
1612  */
1613 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1614 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1615 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1616 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1617 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1618 };
1619 
1620 
1621 /**
1622  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1623  *
1624  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1625  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1626  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1627  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1628  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1629  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1630  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1631  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1632  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1633  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1634  */
1635 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1636 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1637 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1638 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1639 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1640 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1641 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1642 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1643 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1644 };
1645 
1646 /**
1647  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1648  *
1649  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1650  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1651  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1652  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1653  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1654  */
1655 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1656 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1657 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1658 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1659 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1660 
1661 	/* keep last */
1662 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1663 };
1664 
1665 /**
1666  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1667  *
1668  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1669  *
1670  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1671  *
1672  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1673  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1674  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1675  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1676  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1677  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1678  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1679  *
1680  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1681  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1682  *
1683  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1684  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1685  *
1686  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1687  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1688  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1689  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1690  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1691  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1692  *
1693  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1694  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1695  *	configured for an HT channel.
1696  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1697  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1698  */
1699 struct ieee80211_conf {
1700 	u32 flags;
1701 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1702 
1703 	u16 listen_interval;
1704 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1705 
1706 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1707 
1708 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1709 	bool radar_enabled;
1710 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1711 };
1712 
1713 /**
1714  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1715  *
1716  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1717  * operation.
1718  *
1719  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1720  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1721  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1722  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1723  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1724  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1725  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1726  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1727  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1728  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1729  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1730   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1731   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1732  */
1733 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1734 	u64 timestamp;
1735 	u32 device_timestamp;
1736 	bool block_tx;
1737 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1738 	u8 count;
1739 	u32 delay;
1740 };
1741 
1742 /**
1743  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1744  *
1745  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1746  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1747  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1748  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1749  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1750  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1751  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1752  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1753  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1754  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1755  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1756  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1757  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1758  */
1759 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1760 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1761 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1762 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1763 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1764 };
1765 
1766 
1767 /**
1768  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1769  *
1770  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1771  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1772  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1773  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1774  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1775  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1776  *	mac80211.
1777  */
1778 
1779 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1780 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1781 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1782 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1783 };
1784 
1785 /**
1786  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1787  * @assoc: association status
1788  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1789  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1790  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1791  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1792  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1793  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k.
1794  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1795  *	P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j.
1796  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1797  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1798  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1799  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1800  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1801  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1802  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1803  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1804  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1805  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1806  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1807  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1808  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1809  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1810  *	(station mode only)
1811  */
1812 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1813 	/* association related data */
1814 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1815 	bool ibss_creator;
1816 	bool ps;
1817 	u16 aid;
1818 	u16 eml_cap;
1819 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1820 
1821 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1822 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1823 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1824 	size_t ssid_len;
1825 	bool s1g;
1826 	bool idle;
1827 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1828 };
1829 
1830 /**
1831  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1832  *
1833  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1834  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1835  *
1836  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1837  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1838  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1839  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1840  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1841  *	indexed by link ID
1842  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1843  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1844  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1845  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1846  * @addr: address of this interface
1847  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1848  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1849  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1850  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1851  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1852  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1853  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1854  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1855  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1856  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1857  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1858  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1859  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1860  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1861  *	restrictions.
1862  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1863  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1864  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1865  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1866  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1867  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1868  *	interface.
1869  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1870  *	for this interface.
1871  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1872  *	sizeof(void \*).
1873  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1874  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1875  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1876  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1877  */
1878 struct ieee80211_vif {
1879 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1880 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1881 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1882 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1883 	u16 valid_links, active_links;
1884 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1885 	bool p2p;
1886 
1887 	u8 cab_queue;
1888 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1889 
1890 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1891 
1892 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1893 	u32 driver_flags;
1894 	u32 offload_flags;
1895 
1896 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1897 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1898 #endif
1899 
1900 	bool probe_req_reg;
1901 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1902 
1903 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1904 
1905 	/* must be last */
1906 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1907 };
1908 
1909 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1910 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1911 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1912 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1913 		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1914 
1915 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1916 {
1917 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1918 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1919 #endif
1920 	return false;
1921 }
1922 
1923 /**
1924  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1925  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1926  *
1927  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1928  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1929  *
1930  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1931  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1932  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1933  */
1934 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1935 
1936 /**
1937  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1938  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1939  *
1940  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1941  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1942  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1943  */
1944 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1945 
1946 /**
1947  * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1948  * @vif: the interface to check
1949  */
1950 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1951 {
1952 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1953 }
1954 
1955 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1956 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1957 				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1958 
1959 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1960 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1961 			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1962 
1963 /**
1964  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1965  *
1966  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1967  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1968  *
1969  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1970  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1971  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1972  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1973  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1974  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1975  *	generation in software.
1976  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1977  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1978  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1979  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1980  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1981  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1982  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1983  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1984  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1985  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1986  *	MIC.
1987  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1988  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1989  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1990  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1991  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1992  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1993  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1994  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1995  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1996  *	only for management frames (MFP).
1997  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1998  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1999  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2000  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2001  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2002  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2003  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2004  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2005  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2006  *	generation only
2007  */
2008 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2009 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2010 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2011 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2012 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2013 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2014 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2015 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2016 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2017 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2018 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2019 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2020 };
2021 
2022 /**
2023  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2024  *
2025  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2026  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2027  *
2028  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2029  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2030  *	encrypted in hardware.
2031  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2032  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2033  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2034  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2035  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2036  * @keylen: key material length
2037  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2038  * 	data block:
2039  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2040  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2041  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2042  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2043  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2044  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2045  */
2046 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2047 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2048 	u32 cipher;
2049 	u8 icv_len;
2050 	u8 iv_len;
2051 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2052 	s8 keyidx;
2053 	u16 flags;
2054 	s8 link_id;
2055 	u8 keylen;
2056 	u8 key[];
2057 };
2058 
2059 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2060 
2061 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2062 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2063 
2064 /**
2065  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2066  *
2067  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2068  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2069  *	reverse order than in packet)
2070  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2071  *	reverse order than in packet)
2072  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2073  *	reverse order than in packet)
2074  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2075  *	reverse order than in packet)
2076  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2077  */
2078 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2079 	union {
2080 		struct {
2081 			u32 iv32;
2082 			u16 iv16;
2083 		} tkip;
2084 		struct {
2085 			u8 pn[6];
2086 		} ccmp;
2087 		struct {
2088 			u8 pn[6];
2089 		} aes_cmac;
2090 		struct {
2091 			u8 pn[6];
2092 		} aes_gmac;
2093 		struct {
2094 			u8 pn[6];
2095 		} gcmp;
2096 		struct {
2097 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2098 			u8 seq_len;
2099 		} hw;
2100 	};
2101 };
2102 
2103 /**
2104  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2105  *
2106  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2107  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2108  *
2109  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2110  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2111  */
2112 enum set_key_cmd {
2113 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2114 };
2115 
2116 /**
2117  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2118  *
2119  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2120  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2121  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2122  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2123  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2124  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2125  */
2126 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2127 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2128 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2129 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2130 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2131 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2132 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2133 };
2134 
2135 /**
2136  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2137  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2138  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2139  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2140  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2141  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2142  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2143  *
2144  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2145  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2146  */
2147 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2148 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2149 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2150 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2151 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2152 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2153 };
2154 
2155 /**
2156  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2157  *
2158  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2159  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2160  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2161  */
2162 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2163 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2164 	struct {
2165 		s8 idx;
2166 		u8 count;
2167 		u8 count_cts;
2168 		u8 count_rts;
2169 		u16 flags;
2170 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2171 };
2172 
2173 /**
2174  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2175  *
2176  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2177  *
2178  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2179  *	to the STA.
2180  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2181  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2182  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2183  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2184  *	per peer TPC.
2185  */
2186 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2187 	s16 power;
2188 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2189 };
2190 
2191 /**
2192  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2193  *
2194  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2195  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2196  *
2197  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2198  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2199  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2200  *
2201  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2202  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2203  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2204  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2205  *
2206  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2207  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2208  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2209  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2210  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2211  */
2212 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2213 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2214 
2215 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2216 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2217 };
2218 
2219 /**
2220  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2221  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2222  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2223  *
2224  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2225  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2226  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2227  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2228  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2229  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2230  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2231  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2232  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2233  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2234  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2235  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2236  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2237  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2238  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2239  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2240  *	the station moves to associated state.
2241  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2242  *
2243  */
2244 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2245 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2246 
2247 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2248 	u8 link_id;
2249 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2250 
2251 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2252 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2253 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2254 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2255 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2256 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2257 
2258 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2259 
2260 	u8 rx_nss;
2261 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2262 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2263 };
2264 
2265 /**
2266  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2267  *
2268  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2269  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2270  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2271  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2272  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2273  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2274  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2275  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2276  *
2277  * @addr: MAC address
2278  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2279  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2280  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2281  *	Can be modified by driver.
2282  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2283  *	otherwise always false)
2284  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2285  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2286  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2287  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2288  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2289  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2290  * @rates: rate control selection table
2291  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2292  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2293  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2294  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2295  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2296  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2297  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2298  *	unlimited.
2299  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2300  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2301  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2302  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2303  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2304  *	is used for non-data frames
2305  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2306  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2307  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2308  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2309  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2310  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2311  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2312  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2313  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2314  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2315  *	by the AP.
2316  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2317  */
2318 struct ieee80211_sta {
2319 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2320 	u16 aid;
2321 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2322 	bool wme;
2323 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2324 	u8 max_sp;
2325 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2326 	bool tdls;
2327 	bool tdls_initiator;
2328 	bool mfp;
2329 	bool mlo;
2330 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2331 
2332 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2333 
2334 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2335 
2336 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2337 
2338 	u16 valid_links;
2339 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2340 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2341 
2342 	/* must be last */
2343 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2344 };
2345 
2346 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2347 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2348 #else
2349 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2350 {
2351 	return true;
2352 }
2353 #endif
2354 
2355 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2356 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2357 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2358 
2359 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2360 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2361 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2362 
2363 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2364 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2365 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2366 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2367 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2368 
2369 /**
2370  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2371  *
2372  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2373  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2374  *
2375  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2376  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2377  */
2378 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2379 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2380 };
2381 
2382 /**
2383  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2384  *
2385  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2386  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2387  */
2388 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2389 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2390 };
2391 
2392 /**
2393  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2394  *
2395  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2396  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2397  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2398  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2399  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2400  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2401  *
2402  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2403  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2404  */
2405 struct ieee80211_txq {
2406 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2407 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2408 	u8 tid;
2409 	u8 ac;
2410 
2411 	/* must be last */
2412 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2413 };
2414 
2415 /**
2416  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2417  *
2418  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2419  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2420  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2421  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2422  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2423  *
2424  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2425  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2426  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2427  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2428  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2429  *	algorithm.
2430  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2431  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2432  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2433  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2434  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2435  *	CCK frames.
2436  *
2437  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2438  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2439  *	the FCS at the end.
2440  *
2441  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2442  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2443  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2444  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2445  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2446  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2447  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2448  *
2449  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2450  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2451  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2452  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2453  *
2454  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2455  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2456  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2457  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2458  *
2459  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2460  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2461  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2462  *
2463  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2464  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2465  *
2466  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2467  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2468  *
2469  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2470  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2471  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2472  *
2473  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2474  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2475  *
2476  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2477  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2478  *
2479  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2480  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2481  *	the stack.
2482  *
2483  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2484  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2485  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2486  *
2487  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2488  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2489  *	dtim_period).
2490  *
2491  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2492  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2493  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2494  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2495  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2496  *	only in that case.
2497  *
2498  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2499  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2500  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2501  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2502  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2503  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2504  *
2505  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2506  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2507  *	software.
2508  *
2509  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2510  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2511  *	active interfaces.
2512  *
2513  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2514  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2515  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2516  *
2517  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2518  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2519  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2520  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2521  *	supported cipher suites.
2522  *
2523  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2524  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2525  *	for frames.
2526  *
2527  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2528  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2529  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2530  *	control for more details.
2531  *
2532  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2533  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2534  *
2535  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2536  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2537  *	is supported.
2538  *
2539  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2540  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2541  *
2542  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2543  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2544  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2545  *
2546  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2547  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2548  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2549  *	CSA frame.
2550  *
2551  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2552  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2553  *
2554  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2555  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2556  *
2557  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2558  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2559  *
2560  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2561  *	within A-MPDU.
2562  *
2563  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2564  *	for sent beacons.
2565  *
2566  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2567  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2568  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2569  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2570  *
2571  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2572  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2573  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2574  *	timeout.
2575  *
2576  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2577  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2578  *
2579  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2580  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2581  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2582  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2583  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2584  *
2585  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2586  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2587  *
2588  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2589  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2590  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2591  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2592  *
2593  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2594  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2595  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2596  *
2597  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2598  *	TDLS links.
2599  *
2600  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2601  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2602  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2603  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2604  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2605  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2606  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2607  *
2608  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2609  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2610  *
2611  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2612  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2613  *
2614  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2615  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2616  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2617  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2618  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2619  *
2620  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2621  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2622  *	TXQs to start with.
2623  *
2624  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2625  *	length in tx status information
2626  *
2627  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2628  *
2629  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2630  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2631  *
2632  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2633  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2634  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2635  *
2636  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2637  *	offload
2638  *
2639  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2640  *	offload
2641  *
2642  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2643  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2644  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2645  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2646  *	the stack.
2647  *
2648  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2649  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2650  *
2651  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2652  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2653  *
2654  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2655  */
2656 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2657 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2658 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2659 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2660 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2661 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2662 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2663 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2664 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2665 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2666 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2667 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2668 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2669 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2670 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2671 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2672 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2673 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2674 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2675 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2676 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2677 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2678 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2679 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2680 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2681 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2682 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2683 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2684 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2685 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2686 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2687 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2688 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2689 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2690 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2691 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2692 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2693 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2694 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2695 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2696 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2697 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2698 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2699 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2700 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2701 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2702 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2703 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2704 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2705 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2706 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2707 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2708 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2709 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2710 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2711 
2712 	/* keep last, obviously */
2713 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2714 };
2715 
2716 /**
2717  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2718  *
2719  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2720  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2721  *
2722  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2723  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2724  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2725  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2726  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2727  *
2728  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2729  *
2730  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2731  *	along with this structure.
2732  *
2733  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2734  *
2735  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2736  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2737  *
2738  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2739  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2740  *
2741  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2742  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2743  *
2744  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2745  *	that HW supports
2746  *
2747  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2748  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2749  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2750  *
2751  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2752  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2753  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2754  *
2755  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2756  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2757  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2758  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2759  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2760  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2761  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2762  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2763  *
2764  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2765  *	can handle.
2766  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2767  *	the hw can report back.
2768  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2769  *
2770  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2771  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2772  *	aggregation.
2773  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2774  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2775  *	it shouldn't be set.
2776  *
2777  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2778  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2779  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2780  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2781  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2782  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2783  *
2784  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2785  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2786  *
2787  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2788  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2789  *
2790  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2791  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2792  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2793  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2794  *
2795  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2796  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2797  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2798  *
2799  * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2800  *
2801  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2802  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2803  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2804  *	device_timestamp.
2805  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2806  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2807  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2808  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2809  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2810  *
2811  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2812  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2813  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2814  *
2815  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2816  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2817  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2818  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2819  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2820  *	neither enabled.
2821  *
2822  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2823  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2824  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2825  *
2826  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2827  *	device.
2828  *
2829  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2830  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2831  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2832  *
2833  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2834  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2835  *
2836  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2837  *
2838  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2839  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2840  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2841  *
2842  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2843  */
2844 struct ieee80211_hw {
2845 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2846 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2847 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2848 	void *priv;
2849 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2850 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2851 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2852 	int vif_data_size;
2853 	int sta_data_size;
2854 	int chanctx_data_size;
2855 	int txq_data_size;
2856 	u16 queues;
2857 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2858 	s8 max_signal;
2859 	u8 max_rates;
2860 	u8 max_report_rates;
2861 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2862 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2863 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2864 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2865 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2866 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2867 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2868 	struct {
2869 		int units_pos;
2870 		s16 accuracy;
2871 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2872 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2873 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2874 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2875 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2876 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2877 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2878 	u32 max_mtu;
2879 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2880 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2881 };
2882 
2883 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2884 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2885 {
2886 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2887 }
2888 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2889 
2890 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2891 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2892 {
2893 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2894 }
2895 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2896 
2897 /**
2898  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2899  *
2900  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2901  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2902  */
2903 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2904 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2905 
2906 	/* Keep last */
2907 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2908 };
2909 
2910 /**
2911  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2912  *
2913  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2914  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2915  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2916  * @status: channel-switch response status
2917  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2918  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2919  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2920  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2921  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2922  */
2923 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2924 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2925 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2926 	u8 action_code;
2927 	u32 status;
2928 	u32 timestamp;
2929 	u16 switch_time;
2930 	u16 switch_timeout;
2931 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2932 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2933 };
2934 
2935 /**
2936  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2937  *
2938  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2939  *
2940  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2941  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2942  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2943  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2944  * is already used internally by mac80211.
2945  *
2946  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2947  */
2948 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2949 
2950 /**
2951  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2952  *
2953  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2954  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2955  */
2956 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2957 {
2958 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2959 }
2960 
2961 /**
2962  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2963  *
2964  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2965  * @addr: the address to set
2966  */
2967 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2968 {
2969 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2970 }
2971 
2972 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2973 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2974 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2975 {
2976 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2977 		return NULL;
2978 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2979 }
2980 
2981 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2982 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2983 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2984 {
2985 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2986 		return NULL;
2987 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2988 }
2989 
2990 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2991 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2992 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2993 {
2994 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2995 		return NULL;
2996 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2997 }
2998 
2999 /**
3000  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3001  * @hw: the hardware
3002  * @skb: the skb
3003  *
3004  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3005  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3006  */
3007 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3008 
3009 /**
3010  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3011  *
3012  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3013  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3014  *
3015  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3016  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3017  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3018  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3019  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3020  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3021  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3022  *
3023  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3024  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3025  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3026  *
3027  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3028  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3029  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3030  * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3031  *
3032  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3033  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3034  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3035  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3036  *
3037  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3038  *
3039  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3040  * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3041  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3042  * based on the receive flags.
3043  *
3044  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3045  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3046  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3047  * keys.
3048  *
3049  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3050  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3051  * handler.
3052  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3053  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3054  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3055  * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3056  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3057  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3058  *
3059  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3060  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3061  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3062  *
3063  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3064  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3065  * requirements:
3066  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3067       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3068    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3069       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3070    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3071       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3072       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3073    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3074    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3075  */
3076 
3077 /**
3078  * DOC: Powersave support
3079  *
3080  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3081  *
3082  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3083  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3084  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3085  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3086  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3087  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3088  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3089  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3090  *
3091  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3092  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3093  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3094  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3095  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3096  *
3097  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3098  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3099  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3100  *
3101  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3102  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3103  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3104  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3105  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3106  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3107  * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3108  *
3109  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3110  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3111  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3112  * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3113  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3114  * periods.
3115  *
3116  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3117  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3118  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3119  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3120  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3121  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3122  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3123  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3124  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3125  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3126  *
3127  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3128  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3129  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3130  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3131  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3132  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3133  *
3134  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3135  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3136  */
3137 
3138 /**
3139  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3140  *
3141  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3142  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3143  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3144  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3145  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3146  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3147  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3148  *
3149  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3150  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3151  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3152  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3153  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3154  *
3155  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3156  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3157  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3158  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3159  *
3160  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3161  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3162  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3163  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3164  *
3165  *  - a list of information element IDs
3166  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3167  *
3168  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3169  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3170  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3171  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3172  * vendor information elements.
3173  *
3174  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3175  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3176  *
3177  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3178  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3179  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3180  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3181  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3182  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3183  *
3184  *
3185  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3186  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3187  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3188  * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3189  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3190  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3191  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3192  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3193  *
3194  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3195  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3196  * signal strength threshold checking.
3197  */
3198 
3199 /**
3200  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3201  *
3202  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3203  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3204  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3205  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3206  *
3207  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3208  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3209  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3210  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3211  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3212  * hardware flags.
3213  *
3214  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3215  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3216  * turned off otherwise.
3217  *
3218  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3219  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3220  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3221  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3222  */
3223 
3224 /**
3225  * DOC: Frame filtering
3226  *
3227  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3228  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3229  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3230  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3231  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3232  *
3233  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3234  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3235  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3236  *
3237  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3238  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3239  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3240  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3241  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3242  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3243  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3244  *
3245  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3246  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3247  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3248  * or dropped.
3249  *
3250  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3251  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3252  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3253  * the flag, but not clear it.
3254  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3255  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3256  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3257  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3258  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3259  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3260  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3261  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3262  */
3263 
3264 /**
3265  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3266  *
3267  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3268  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3269  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3270  *
3271  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3272  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3273  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3274  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3275  * the driver code.
3276  *
3277  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3278  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3279  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3280  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3281  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3282  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3283  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3284  *
3285  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3286  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3287  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3288  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3289  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3290  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3291  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3292  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3293  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3294  * @sta_notify callback.
3295  *
3296  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3297  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3298  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3299  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3300  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3301  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3302  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3303  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3304  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3305  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3306  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3307  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3308  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3309  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3310  *
3311  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3312  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3313  *
3314  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3315  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3316  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3317  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3318  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3319  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3320  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3321  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3322  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3323  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3324  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3325  *
3326  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3327  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3328  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3329  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3330  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3331  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3332  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3333  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3334  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3335  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3336  * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3337  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3338  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3339  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3340  *
3341  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3342  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3343  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3344  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3345  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3346  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3347  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3348  *
3349  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3350  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3351  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3352  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3353  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3354  *
3355  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3356  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3357  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3358  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3359  */
3360 
3361 /**
3362  * DOC: HW queue control
3363  *
3364  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3365  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3366  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3367  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3368  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3369  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3370  *
3371  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3372  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3373  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3374  *
3375  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3376  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3377  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3378  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3379  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3380  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3381  * the hardware queue.
3382  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3383  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3384  *
3385  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3386  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3387  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3388  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3389  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3390  *
3391  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3392  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3393  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3394  * off-channel queue:         9
3395  *
3396  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3397  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3398  *
3399  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3400  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3401  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3402  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3403  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3404  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3405  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3406  *
3407  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3408  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3409  *
3410  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3411  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3412  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3413  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3414  */
3415 
3416 /**
3417  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3418  *
3419  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3420  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3421  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3422  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3423  *
3424  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3425  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3426  *	multicast address.
3427  *
3428  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3429  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3430  *
3431  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3432  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3433  *
3434  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3435  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3436  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3437  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3438  *	honour this flag if possible.
3439  *
3440  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3441  *	station
3442  *
3443  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3444  *
3445  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3446  *
3447  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3448  *
3449  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3450  */
3451 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3452 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3453 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3454 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3455 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3456 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3457 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3458 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3459 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3460 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3461 };
3462 
3463 /**
3464  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3465  *
3466  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3467  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3468  *
3469  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3470  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3471  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3472  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3473  *
3474  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3475  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3476  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3477  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3478  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3479  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3480  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3481  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3482  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3483  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3484  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3485  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3486  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3487  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3488  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3489  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3490  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3491  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3492  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3493  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3494  */
3495 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3496 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3497 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3498 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3499 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3500 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3501 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3502 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3503 };
3504 
3505 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3506 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3507 
3508 /**
3509  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3510  *
3511  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3512  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3513  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3514  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3515  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3516  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3517  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3518  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3519  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3520  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3521  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3522  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3523  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3524  */
3525 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3526 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3527 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3528 	u16 tid;
3529 	u16 ssn;
3530 	u16 buf_size;
3531 	bool amsdu;
3532 	u16 timeout;
3533 };
3534 
3535 /**
3536  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3537  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3538  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3539  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3540  */
3541 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3542 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3543 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3544 };
3545 
3546 /**
3547  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3548  *
3549  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3550  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3551  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3552  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3553  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3554  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3555  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3556  *	the peer.
3557  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3558  *	by the peer
3559  */
3560 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3561 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3562 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3563 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3564 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3565 };
3566 
3567 /**
3568  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3569  *
3570  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3571  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3572  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3573  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3574  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3575  *
3576  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3577  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3578  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3579  */
3580 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3581 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3582 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3583 };
3584 
3585 /**
3586  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3587  *
3588  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3589  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3590  *
3591  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3592  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3593  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3594  *	of wowlan configuration)
3595  */
3596 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3597 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3598 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3599 };
3600 
3601 /**
3602  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3603  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3604  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3605  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3606  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3607  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3608  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3609  */
3610 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3611 	u16 duration;
3612 	u16 subtype;
3613 	u8 success:1;
3614 };
3615 
3616 /**
3617  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3618  *
3619  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3620  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3621  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3622  *
3623  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3624  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3625  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3626  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3627  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3628  *	Must be atomic.
3629  *
3630  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3631  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3632  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3633  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3634  *	or zero.
3635  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3636  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3637  *	is added.
3638  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3639  *
3640  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3641  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3642  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3643  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3644  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3645  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3646  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3647  *
3648  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3649  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3650  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3651  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3652  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3653  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3654  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3655  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3656  *	must return 1 from this function.
3657  *
3658  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3659  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3660  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3661  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3662  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3663  *
3664  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3665  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3666  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3667  *	in suspend().
3668  *
3669  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3670  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3671  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3672  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3673  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3674  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3675  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3676  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3677  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3678  *
3679  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3680  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3681  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3682  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3683  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3684  *
3685  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3686  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3687  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3688  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3689  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3690  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3691  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3692  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3693  *
3694  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3695  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3696  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3697  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3698  *
3699  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3700  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3701  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3702  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3703  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3704  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3705  *	can sleep.
3706  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3707  *	are not implemented.
3708  *
3709  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3710  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3711  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3712  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3713  *	The callback can sleep.
3714  *
3715  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3716  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3717  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3718  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3719  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3720  *	non-MLO connections.
3721  *	The callback can sleep.
3722  *
3723  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3724  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3725  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3726  *
3727  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3728  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3729  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3730  *
3731  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3732  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3733  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3734  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3735  *	which flags are changed.
3736  *	This callback can sleep.
3737  *
3738  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3739  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3740  *
3741  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3742  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3743  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3744  *	is enabled.
3745  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3746  *	The callback can sleep.
3747  *
3748  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3749  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3750  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3751  *	The callback must be atomic.
3752  *
3753  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3754  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3755  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3756  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3757  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3758  *
3759  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3760  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3761  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3762  *
3763  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3764  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3765  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3766  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3767  *	that power save is disabled.
3768  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3769  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3770  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3771  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3772  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3773  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3774  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3775  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3776  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3777  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3778  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3779  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3780  *	The callback can sleep.
3781  *
3782  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3783  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3784  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3785  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3786  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3787  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3788  *	The callback can sleep.
3789  *
3790  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3791  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3792  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3793  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3794  *
3795  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3796  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3797  *
3798  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3799  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3800  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3801  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3802  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3803  *
3804  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3805  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3806  *	this notification.
3807  *	The callback can sleep.
3808  *
3809  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3810  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3811  *	The callback can sleep.
3812  *
3813  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3814  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3815  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3816  *	The callback must be atomic.
3817  *
3818  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3819  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3820  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3821  *	should be set as well.
3822  *	The callback can sleep.
3823  *
3824  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3825  *	The callback can sleep.
3826  *
3827  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3828  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3829  *
3830  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3831  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3832  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3833  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3834  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3835  *	This callback can sleep.
3836  *
3837  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3838  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3839  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3840  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3841  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3842  *
3843  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3844  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3845  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3846  *	callback can sleep.
3847  *
3848  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3849  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3850  *	should be within a CPTCFG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3851  *	callback can sleep.
3852  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3853  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3854  *
3855  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3856  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3857  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3858  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3859  *
3860  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3861  *	power for the station.
3862  *	This callback can sleep.
3863  *
3864  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3865  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3866  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3867  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3868  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3869  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3870  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3871  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3872  *	The callback can sleep.
3873  *
3874  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3875  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3876  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3877  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3878  *	in @sta_state.
3879  *	The callback can sleep.
3880  *
3881  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3882  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3883  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3884  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3885  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3886  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3887  *	Must be atomic.
3888  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3889  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3890  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3891  *
3892  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3893  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3894  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3895  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3896  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3897  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3898  *	The callback can sleep.
3899  *
3900  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3901  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3902  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3903  *	The callback can sleep.
3904  *
3905  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3906  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3907  *	required function.
3908  *	The callback can sleep.
3909  *
3910  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3911  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3912  *	required function.
3913  *	The callback can sleep.
3914  *
3915  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3916  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3917  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3918  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3919  *	The callback can sleep.
3920  *
3921  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3922  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3923  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3924  *	TSF synchronization.
3925  *	The callback can sleep.
3926  *
3927  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3928  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3929  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3930  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3931  *	The callback can sleep.
3932  *
3933  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3934  *
3935  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3936  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3937  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3938  *	The callback can sleep.
3939  *
3940  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3941  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3942  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3943  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3944  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3945  *
3946  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3947  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3948  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3949  *
3950  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3951  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3952  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3953  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3954  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3955  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3956  *	The callback can sleep.
3957  *
3958  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
3959  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
3960  *	The callback can sleep.
3961  *
3962  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3963  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3964  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3965  *	completion of the channel switch.
3966  *
3967  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3968  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3969  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3970  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3971  *
3972  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3973  *
3974  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3975  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3976  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3977  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3978  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3979  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3980  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3981  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3982  *	must be accepted in this case.
3983  *	This callback may sleep.
3984  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3985  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3986  *
3987  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3988  *
3989  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3990  *
3991  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3992  *	queues before entering power save.
3993  *
3994  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3995  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3996  *	The callback can sleep.
3997  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3998  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3999  *	The callback must be atomic.
4000  *
4001  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4002  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4003  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4004  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4005  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4006  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4007  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4008  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4009  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4010  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4011  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4012  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4013  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4014  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4015  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4016  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4017  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4018  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4019  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4020  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4021  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4022  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4023  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4024  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4025  *	This callback must be atomic.
4026  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4027  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4028  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4029  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4030  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4031  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4032  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4033  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4034  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4035  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4036  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4037  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4038  *	This callback must be atomic.
4039  *
4040  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4041  *
4042  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4043  *
4044  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4045  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4046  *
4047  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4048  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4049  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4050  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4051  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4052  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4053  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4054  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4055  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4056  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4057  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4058  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4059  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4060  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4061  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4062  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4063  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4064  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4065  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4066  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4067  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4068  *
4069  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4070  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4071  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4072  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4073  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4074  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4075  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4076  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4077  *
4078  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4079  *	This callback may sleep.
4080  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4081  *	This callback may sleep.
4082  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4083  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4084  *	channel context with different settings
4085  *	This callback may sleep.
4086  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4087  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4088  *	This callback may sleep.
4089  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4090  *	unbound from vif.
4091  *	This callback may sleep.
4092  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4093  *	another, as specified in the list of
4094  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4095  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4096  *	This callback may sleep.
4097  *
4098  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4099  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4100  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4101  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4102  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4103  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4104  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4105  *
4106  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4107  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4108  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4109  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4110  *	This callback may sleep.
4111  *
4112  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4113  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4114  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4115  *
4116  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4117  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4118  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4119  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4120  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4121  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4122  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4123  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4124  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4125  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4126  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4127  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4128  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4129  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4130  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4131  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4132  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4133  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4134  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4135  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4136  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4137  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4138  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4139  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4140  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4141  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4142  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4143  *
4144  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4145  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4146  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4147  *
4148  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4149  *	and hardware limits.
4150  *
4151  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4152  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4153  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4154  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4155  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4156  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4157  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4158  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4159  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4160  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4161  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4162  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4163  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4164  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4165  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4166  *	the function call.
4167  *
4168  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4169  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4170  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4171  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4172  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4173  *
4174  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4175  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4176  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4177  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4178  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4179  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4180  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4181  *	changed parameters.
4182  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4183  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4184  *	this call.
4185  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4186  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4187  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4188  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4189  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4190  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4191  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4192  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4193  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4194  *
4195  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4196  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4197  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4198  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4199  *	This callback may sleep.
4200  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4201  *	This callback may sleep.
4202  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4203  *	4-address mode
4204  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4205  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4206  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4207  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4208  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4209  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4210  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4211  *	twt structure.
4212  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4213  *	from the peer.
4214  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4215  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4216  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4217  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4218  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4219  *	radar channel.
4220  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4221  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4222  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4223  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4224  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4225  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4226  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4227  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4228  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4229  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4230  *	This callback can sleep.
4231  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4232  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4233  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4234  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4235  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4236  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4237  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4238  *	that.
4239  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4240  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4241  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4242  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4243  */
4244 struct ieee80211_ops {
4245 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4246 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4247 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4248 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4249 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4250 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4251 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4252 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4253 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4254 #endif
4255 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4256 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4257 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4258 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4259 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4260 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4261 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4262 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4263 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4264 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4265 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4266 				 u64 changed);
4267 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4268 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4269 				u64 changed);
4270 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4271 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4272 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4273 				  u64 changed);
4274 
4275 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4276 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4277 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4278 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4279 
4280 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4281 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4282 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4283 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4284 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4285 				 u64 multicast);
4286 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4287 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4288 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4289 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4290 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4291 		       bool set);
4292 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4293 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4294 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4295 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4296 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4297 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4298 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4299 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4300 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4301 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4302 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4303 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4304 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4305 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4306 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4307 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4308 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4309 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4310 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4311 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4312 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4313 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4314 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4315 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4316 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4317 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4318 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4319 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4320 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4321 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4322 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4323 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4324 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4325 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4326 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4327 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4328 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4329 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4330 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4331 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4332 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4333 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4334 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4335 				 struct dentry *dir);
4336 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4337 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4338 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4339 				struct dentry *dir);
4340 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4341 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4342 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4343 				     struct dentry *dir);
4344 #endif
4345 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4346 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4347 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4348 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4349 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4350 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4351 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4352 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4353 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4354 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4355 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4356 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4357 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4358 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4359 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4360 			      u32 changed);
4361 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4362 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4363 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4364 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4365 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4366 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4367 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4368 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4369 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4370 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4371 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4372 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4373 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4374 			u64 tsf);
4375 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4376 			   s64 offset);
4377 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4378 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4379 
4380 	/**
4381 	 * @ampdu_action:
4382 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4383 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4384 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4385 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4386 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4387 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4388 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4389 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4390 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4391 	 *
4392 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4393 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4394 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4395 	 *
4396 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4397 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4398 	 *
4399 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4400 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4401 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4402 	 *
4403 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4404 	 *
4405 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4406 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4407 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4408 	 *
4409 	 * The callback can sleep.
4410 	 */
4411 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4412 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4413 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4414 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4415 		struct survey_info *survey);
4416 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4417 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4418 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4419 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4420 			    void *data, int len);
4421 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4422 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4423 			     void *data, int len);
4424 #endif
4425 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4426 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4427 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4428 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4429 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4430 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4431 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4432 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4433 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4434 
4435 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4436 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4437 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4438 				 int duration,
4439 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4440 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4441 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4442 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4443 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4444 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4445 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4446 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4447 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4448 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4449 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4450 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4451 
4452 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4453 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4454 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4455 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4456 				      bool more_data);
4457 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4458 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4459 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4460 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4461 					bool more_data);
4462 
4463 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4464 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4465 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4466 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4467 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4468 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4469 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4470 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4471 
4472 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4473 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4474 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4475 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4476 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4477 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4478 
4479 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4480 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4481 
4482 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4483 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4484 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4485 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4486 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4488 			       u32 changed);
4489 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4490 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4491 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4492 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4493 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4494 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4495 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4496 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4497 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4499 				  int n_vifs,
4500 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4501 
4502 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4503 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4504 
4505 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4506 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4507 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4508 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4509 #endif
4510 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4512 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4513 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4514 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4515 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4516 
4517 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4518 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4519 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4520 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4521 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4522 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4523 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4524 
4525 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4526 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4527 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4528 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4529 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4530 			   int *dbm);
4531 
4532 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4533 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4535 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4536 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4537 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4540 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4541 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4542 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4543 
4544 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4545 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4546 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4547 
4548 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4549 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4550 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4551 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4552 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4553 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4554 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4555 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4556 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4558 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4559 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4560 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4561 			    u8 instance_id);
4562 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4564 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4565 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4566 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4567 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4568 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4569 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4570 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4572 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4574 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4575 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4576 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4578 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4579 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4580 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4581 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4582 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4583 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4584 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4585 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4588 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4589 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4590 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4591 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4593 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4594 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4595 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4596 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4597 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4598 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4599 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4600 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4601 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4602 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4603 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4604 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4605 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4606 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4607 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4608 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4610 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4611 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4612 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4613 			    struct net_device *dev,
4614 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4615 			    void *type_data);
4616 };
4617 
4618 /**
4619  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4620  *
4621  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4622  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4623  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4624  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4625  * @priv_data_len.
4626  *
4627  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4628  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4629  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4630  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4631  *
4632  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4633  */
4634 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4635 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4636 					   const char *requested_name);
4637 
4638 /**
4639  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4640  *
4641  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4642  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4643  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4644  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4645  * @priv_data_len.
4646  *
4647  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4648  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4649  *
4650  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4651  */
4652 static inline
4653 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4654 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4655 {
4656 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4657 }
4658 
4659 /**
4660  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4661  *
4662  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4663  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4664  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4665  *
4666  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4667  *
4668  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4669  */
4670 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4671 
4672 /**
4673  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4674  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4675  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4676  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4677  */
4678 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4679 	int throughput;
4680 	int blink_time;
4681 };
4682 
4683 /**
4684  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4685  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4686  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4687  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4688  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4689  */
4690 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4691 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4692 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4693 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4694 };
4695 
4696 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4697 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4698 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4699 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4700 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4701 const char *
4702 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4703 				   unsigned int flags,
4704 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4705 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4706 #endif
4707 /**
4708  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4709  *
4710  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4711  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4712  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4713  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4714  *
4715  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4716  *
4717  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4718  */
4719 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4720 {
4721 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4722 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4723 #else
4724 	return NULL;
4725 #endif
4726 }
4727 
4728 /**
4729  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4730  *
4731  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4732  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4733  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4734  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4735  *
4736  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4737  *
4738  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4739  */
4740 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4741 {
4742 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4743 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4744 #else
4745 	return NULL;
4746 #endif
4747 }
4748 
4749 /**
4750  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4751  *
4752  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4753  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4754  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4755  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4756  *
4757  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4758  *
4759  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4760  */
4761 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4762 {
4763 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4764 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4765 #else
4766 	return NULL;
4767 #endif
4768 }
4769 
4770 /**
4771  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4772  *
4773  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4774  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4775  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4776  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4777  *
4778  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4779  *
4780  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4781  */
4782 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4783 {
4784 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4785 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4786 #else
4787 	return NULL;
4788 #endif
4789 }
4790 
4791 /**
4792  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4793  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4794  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4795  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4796  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4797  *
4798  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4799  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4800  *
4801  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4802  */
4803 static inline const char *
4804 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4805 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4806 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4807 {
4808 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4809 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4810 						  blink_table_len);
4811 #else
4812 	return NULL;
4813 #endif
4814 }
4815 
4816 /**
4817  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4818  *
4819  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4820  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4821  *
4822  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4823  */
4824 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4825 
4826 /**
4827  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4828  *
4829  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4830  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4831  * before calling this function.
4832  *
4833  * @hw: the hardware to free
4834  */
4835 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4836 
4837 /**
4838  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4839  *
4840  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4841  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4842  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4843  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4844  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4845  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4846  *
4847  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4848  */
4849 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4850 
4851 /**
4852  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4853  *
4854  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4855  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4856  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4857  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4858  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4859  *
4860  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4861  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4862  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4863  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4864  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4865  *
4866  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4867  *
4868  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4869  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4870  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4871  * @list: the destination list
4872  */
4873 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4874 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4875 
4876 /**
4877  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4878  *
4879  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4880  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4881  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4882  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4883  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4884  *
4885  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4886  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4887  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4888  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4889  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4890  *
4891  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4892  *
4893  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4894  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4895  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4896  * @napi: the NAPI context
4897  */
4898 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4899 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4900 
4901 /**
4902  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4903  *
4904  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4905  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4906  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4907  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4908  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4909  *
4910  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4911  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4912  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4913  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4914  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4915  *
4916  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4917  *
4918  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4919  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4920  */
4921 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4922 {
4923 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4924 }
4925 
4926 /**
4927  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4928  *
4929  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4930  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4931  *
4932  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4933  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4934  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4935  *
4936  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4937  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4938  */
4939 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4940 
4941 /**
4942  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4943  *
4944  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4945  * (internally disables bottom halves).
4946  *
4947  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4948  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4949  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4950  *
4951  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4952  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4953  */
4954 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4955 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4956 {
4957 	local_bh_disable();
4958 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4959 	local_bh_enable();
4960 }
4961 
4962 /**
4963  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4964  *
4965  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4966  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4967  * entering/leaving PS mode.
4968  *
4969  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4970  *
4971  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4972  * each other.
4973  *
4974  * @sta: currently connected sta
4975  * @start: start or stop PS
4976  *
4977  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4978  */
4979 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4980 
4981 /**
4982  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4983  *                                  (in process context)
4984  *
4985  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4986  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4987  * applies.
4988  *
4989  * @sta: currently connected sta
4990  * @start: start or stop PS
4991  *
4992  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4993  */
4994 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4995 						  bool start)
4996 {
4997 	int ret;
4998 
4999 	local_bh_disable();
5000 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5001 	local_bh_enable();
5002 
5003 	return ret;
5004 }
5005 
5006 /**
5007  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5008  * @sta: currently connected station
5009  *
5010  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5011  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5012  * connected station was received.
5013  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5014  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5015  * be serialized.
5016  */
5017 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5018 
5019 /**
5020  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5021  * @sta: currently connected station
5022  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5023  *
5024  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5025  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5026  * from a connected station was received.
5027  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5028  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5029  * serialized.
5030  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5031  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5032  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5033  * checks.
5034  */
5035 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5036 
5037 /*
5038  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5039  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5040  */
5041 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5042 
5043 /**
5044  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5045  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5046  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5047  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5048  *
5049  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5050  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5051  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5052  *
5053  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5054  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5055  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5056  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5057  *
5058  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5059  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5060  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5061  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5062  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5063  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5064  *
5065  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5066  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5067  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5068  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5069  * use this API.
5070  */
5071 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5072 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5073 
5074 /**
5075  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5076  *
5077  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5078  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5079  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5080  *
5081  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5082  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5083  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5084  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5085  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5086  */
5087 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5088 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5089 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5090 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5091 			    int max_rates);
5092 
5093 /**
5094  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5095  *
5096  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5097  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5098  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5099  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5100  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5101  * slow stations to starve).
5102  *
5103  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5104  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5105  */
5106 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5107 					   u32 thr);
5108 
5109 /**
5110  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5111  *
5112  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5113  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5114  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5115  *
5116  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5117  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5118  * @info: tx status information
5119  */
5120 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5121 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5122 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5123 
5124 /**
5125  * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5126  *
5127  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5128  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5129  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5130  *
5131  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5132  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5133  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5134  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5135  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5136  *
5137  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5138  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5139  */
5140 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5141 			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5142 
5143 /**
5144  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5145  *
5146  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5147  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5148  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5149  *
5150  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5151  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5152  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5153  *
5154  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5155  * @status: tx status information
5156  */
5157 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5158 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5159 
5160 /**
5161  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5162  *
5163  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5164  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5165  * specific skbs.
5166  *
5167  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5168  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5169  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5170  *
5171  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5172  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5173  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5174  * @info: tx status information
5175  */
5176 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5177 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5178 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5179 {
5180 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5181 		.sta = sta,
5182 		.info = info,
5183 	};
5184 
5185 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5186 }
5187 
5188 /**
5189  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5190  *
5191  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5192  *
5193  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5194  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5195  * for a single hardware.
5196  *
5197  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5198  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5199  */
5200 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5201 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5202 {
5203 	local_bh_disable();
5204 	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5205 	local_bh_enable();
5206 }
5207 
5208 /**
5209  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5210  *
5211  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5212  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5213  *
5214  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5215  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5216  *
5217  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5218  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5219  */
5220 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5221 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5222 
5223 /**
5224  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5225  *
5226  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5227  * connected STA.
5228  *
5229  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5230  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5231  */
5232 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5233 
5234 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5235 
5236 /**
5237  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5238  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5239  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5240  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5241  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5242  *	should be ignored.
5243  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5244  */
5245 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5246 	u16 tim_offset;
5247 	u16 tim_length;
5248 
5249 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5250 	u16 mbssid_off;
5251 };
5252 
5253 /**
5254  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5255  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5256  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5257  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5258  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5259  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5260  *
5261  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5262  * obtain the beacon template.
5263  *
5264  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5265  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5266  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5267  * applicable, the CSA count.
5268  *
5269  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5270  *
5271  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5272  */
5273 struct sk_buff *
5274 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5275 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5276 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5277 			      unsigned int link_id);
5278 
5279 /**
5280  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5281  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5282  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5283  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5284  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5285  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5286  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5287  *
5288  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5289  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5290  * requested index.
5291  *
5292  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5293  */
5294 struct sk_buff *
5295 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5296 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5297 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5298 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5299 
5300 /**
5301  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5302  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5303  *
5304  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5305  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5306  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5307  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5308  */
5309 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5310 	u8 cnt;
5311 	struct {
5312 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5313 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5314 	} bcn[];
5315 };
5316 
5317 /**
5318  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5319  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5320  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5321  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5322  *
5323  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5324  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5325  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5326  * one multiple BSSID element.
5327  *
5328  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5329  *
5330  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5331  *	%NULL on error.
5332  */
5333 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5334 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5335 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5336 				       unsigned int link_id);
5337 
5338 /**
5339  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5340  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5341  *
5342  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5343  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5344  */
5345 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5346 
5347 /**
5348  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5349  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5350  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5351  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5352  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5353  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5354  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5355  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5356  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5357  *
5358  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5359  * obtain the beacon frame.
5360  *
5361  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5362  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5363  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5364  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5365  *
5366  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5367  *
5368  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5369  */
5370 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5371 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5372 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5373 					 unsigned int link_id);
5374 
5375 /**
5376  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5377  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5378  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5379  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5380  *
5381  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5382  *
5383  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5384  */
5385 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5386 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5387 						   unsigned int link_id)
5388 {
5389 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5390 }
5391 
5392 /**
5393  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5394  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5395  *
5396  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5397  * This function is called implicitly when
5398  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5399  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5400  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5401  *
5402  * Return: new countdown value
5403  */
5404 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5405 
5406 /**
5407  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5408  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5409  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5410  *
5411  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5412  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5413  *
5414  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5415  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5416  */
5417 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5418 
5419 /**
5420  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5421  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5422  *
5423  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5424  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5425  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5426  */
5427 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5428 
5429 /**
5430  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5431  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5432  *
5433  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5434  */
5435 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5436 
5437 /**
5438  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5439  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5440  *
5441  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5442  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5443  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5444  */
5445 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5446 
5447 /**
5448  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5449  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5450  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5451  *
5452  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5453  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5454  *
5455  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5456  *
5457  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5458  */
5459 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5460 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5461 
5462 /**
5463  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5464  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5465  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5466  *
5467  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5468  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5469  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5470  *
5471  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5472  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5473  *
5474  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5475  */
5476 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5477 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5478 
5479 /**
5480  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5481  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5482  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5483  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5484  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5485  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5486  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5487  *	if at all possible
5488  *
5489  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5490  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5491  * BSSID and address is used.
5492  *
5493  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5494  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5495  *
5496  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5497  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5498  *
5499  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5500  */
5501 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5502 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5503 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5504 
5505 /**
5506  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5507  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5508  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5509  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5510  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5511  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5512  *
5513  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5514  * hardware.
5515  *
5516  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5517  */
5518 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5519 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5520 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5521 				       size_t tailroom);
5522 
5523 /**
5524  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5525  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5526  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5527  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5528  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5529  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5530  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5531  *
5532  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5533  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5534  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5535  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5536  */
5537 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5538 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5539 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5540 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5541 
5542 /**
5543  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5544  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5545  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5546  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5547  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5548  *
5549  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5550  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5551  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5552  *
5553  * Return: The duration.
5554  */
5555 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5556 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5557 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5558 
5559 /**
5560  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5561  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5562  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5563  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5564  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5565  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5566  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5567  *
5568  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5569  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5570  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5571  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5572  */
5573 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5574 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5575 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5576 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5577 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5578 
5579 /**
5580  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5581  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5582  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5583  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5584  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5585  *
5586  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5587  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5588  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5589  *
5590  * Return: The duration.
5591  */
5592 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5593 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5594 				    size_t frame_len,
5595 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5596 
5597 /**
5598  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5599  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5600  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5601  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5602  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5603  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5604  *
5605  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5606  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5607  *
5608  * Return: The duration.
5609  */
5610 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5611 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5612 					enum nl80211_band band,
5613 					size_t frame_len,
5614 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5615 
5616 /**
5617  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5618  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5619  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5620  *
5621  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5622  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5623  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5624  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5625  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5626  *
5627  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5628  * frames are available.
5629  *
5630  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5631  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5632  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5633  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5634  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5635  * use common code for all beacons.
5636  */
5637 struct sk_buff *
5638 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5639 
5640 /**
5641  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5642  *
5643  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5644  *
5645  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5646  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5647  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5648  */
5649 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5650 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5651 
5652 /**
5653  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5654  *
5655  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5656  * from the given packet.
5657  *
5658  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5659  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5660  *	with this P1K
5661  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5662  */
5663 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5664 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5665 {
5666 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5667 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5668 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5669 
5670 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5671 }
5672 
5673 /**
5674  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5675  *
5676  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5677  * and transmitter address.
5678  *
5679  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5680  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5681  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5682  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5683  */
5684 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5685 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5686 
5687 /**
5688  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5689  *
5690  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5691  * in the packet.
5692  *
5693  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5694  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5695  *	encrypted with this key
5696  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5697  */
5698 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5699 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5700 
5701 /**
5702  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5703  *
5704  * @pos: start of crypto header
5705  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5706  * @pn: PN to add
5707  *
5708  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5709  * the packet payload)
5710  *
5711  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5712  * point to the crypto header)
5713  */
5714 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5715 
5716 /**
5717  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5718  *
5719  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5720  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5721  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5722  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5723  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5724  *
5725  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5726  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5727  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5728  *
5729  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5730  * can be done concurrently.
5731  */
5732 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5733 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5734 
5735 /**
5736  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5737  *
5738  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5739  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5740  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5741  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5742  * @seq: new sequence data
5743  *
5744  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5745  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5746  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5747  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5748  *
5749  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5750  * can be done concurrently.
5751  */
5752 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5753 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5754 
5755 /**
5756  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5757  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5758  *
5759  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5760  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5761  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5762  *
5763  * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5764  * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5765  */
5766 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5767 
5768 /**
5769  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5770  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5771  * @keyconf: new key data
5772  *
5773  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5774  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5775  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5776  *
5777  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5778  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5779  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5780  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5781  *
5782  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5783  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5784  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5785  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5786  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5787  * of the reconfiguration.
5788  *
5789  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5790  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5791  *
5792  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5793  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5794  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5795  * the key that's being replaced.
5796  */
5797 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5798 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5799 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5800 
5801 /**
5802  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5803  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5804  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5805  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5806  * @gfp: allocation flags
5807  */
5808 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5809 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5810 
5811 /**
5812  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5813  *
5814  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5815  * at the same time.
5816  *
5817  * @keyconf: the key in question
5818  */
5819 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5820 
5821 /**
5822  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5823  *
5824  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5825  * at the same time.
5826  *
5827  * @keyconf: the key in question
5828  */
5829 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5830 
5831 /**
5832  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5833  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5834  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5835  *
5836  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5837  */
5838 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5839 
5840 /**
5841  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5842  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5843  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5844  *
5845  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5846  */
5847 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5848 
5849 /**
5850  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5851  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5852  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5853  *
5854  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5855  *
5856  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5857  */
5858 
5859 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5860 
5861 /**
5862  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5863  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5864  *
5865  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5866  */
5867 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5868 
5869 /**
5870  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5871  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5872  *
5873  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5874  */
5875 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5879  *
5880  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5881  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5882  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5883  * any context, including hardirq context.
5884  *
5885  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5886  * @info: information about the completed scan
5887  */
5888 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5889 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5890 
5891 /**
5892  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5893  *
5894  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5895  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5896  *
5897  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5898  */
5899 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5900 
5901 /**
5902  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5903  *
5904  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5905  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5906  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5907  * while associating, for instance.
5908  *
5909  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5910  */
5911 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5912 
5913 /**
5914  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5915  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5916  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5917  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5918  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5919  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5920  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5921  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5922  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5923  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5924  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5925  *	for instance.
5926  */
5927 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5928 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5929 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5930 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5931 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5932 };
5933 
5934 /**
5935  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5936  *
5937  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5938  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5939  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5940  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5941  *
5942  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5943  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5944  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5945  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5946  */
5947 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5948 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5949 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5950 				  void *data);
5951 
5952 /**
5953  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5954  *
5955  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5956  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5957  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5958  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5959  * be used.
5960  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5961  *
5962  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5963  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5964  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5965  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5966  */
5967 static inline void
5968 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5969 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5970 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5971 				    void *data)
5972 {
5973 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5974 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5975 				     iterator, data);
5976 }
5977 
5978 /**
5979  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5980  *
5981  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5982  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5983  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5984  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5985  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5986  *
5987  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5988  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5989  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5990  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5991  */
5992 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5993 						u32 iter_flags,
5994 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5995 						    u8 *mac,
5996 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5997 						void *data);
5998 
5999 /**
6000  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6001  *
6002  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6003  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6004  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6005  *
6006  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6007  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6008  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6009  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6010  */
6011 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6012 					     u32 iter_flags,
6013 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6014 						u8 *mac,
6015 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6016 					     void *data);
6017 
6018 /**
6019  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6020  *
6021  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6022  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6023  * function for them.
6024  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6025  *
6026  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6027  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6028  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6029  */
6030 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6031 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6032 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6033 				       void *data);
6034 /**
6035  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6036  *
6037  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6038  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6039  *
6040  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6041  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6042  */
6043 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6044 
6045 /**
6046  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6047  *
6048  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6049  * workqueue.
6050  *
6051  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6052  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6053  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6054  */
6055 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6056 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6057 				  unsigned long delay);
6058 
6059 /**
6060  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6061  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6062  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6063  *
6064  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6065  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6066  * mac80211.
6067  *
6068  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6069  */
6070 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6071 					    u16 tid);
6072 
6073 /**
6074  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6075  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6076  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6077  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6078  *
6079  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6080  *
6081  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6082  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6083  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6084  */
6085 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6086 				  u16 timeout);
6087 
6088 /**
6089  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6090  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6091  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6092  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6093  *
6094  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6095  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6096  * from any context.
6097  */
6098 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6099 				      u16 tid);
6100 
6101 /**
6102  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6103  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6104  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6105  *
6106  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6107  *
6108  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6109  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6110  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6111  */
6112 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6113 
6114 /**
6115  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6116  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6117  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6118  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6119  *
6120  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6121  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6122  * can be called from any context.
6123  */
6124 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6125 				     u16 tid);
6126 
6127 /**
6128  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6129  *
6130  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6131  * @addr: station's address
6132  *
6133  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6134  *
6135  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6136  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6137  */
6138 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6139 					 const u8 *addr);
6140 
6141 /**
6142  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6143  *
6144  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6145  * @addr: remote station's address
6146  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6147  *
6148  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6149  *
6150  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6151  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6152  *
6153  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6154  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6155  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6156  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6157  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6158  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6159  *      is not reliable.
6160  *
6161  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6162  */
6163 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6164 					       const u8 *addr,
6165 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6166 
6167 /**
6168  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6169  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6170  * @addr: remote station's link address
6171  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6172  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6173  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6174  *
6175  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6176  */
6177 struct ieee80211_sta *
6178 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6179 				 const u8 *addr,
6180 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6181 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6182 
6183 /**
6184  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6185  * @hw: the hardware
6186  * @pubsta: the station
6187  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6188  *
6189  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6190  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6191  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6192  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6193  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6194  *
6195  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6196  * manner.
6197  *
6198  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6199  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6200  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6201  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6202  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6203  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6204  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6205  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6206  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6207  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6208  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6209  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6210  * woke up while blocked or not.
6211  */
6212 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6213 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6214 
6215 /**
6216  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6217  * @pubsta: the station
6218  *
6219  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6220  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6221  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6222  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6223  *
6224  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6225  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6226  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6227  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6228  *
6229  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6230  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6231  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6232  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6233  */
6234 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6235 
6236 /**
6237  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6238  * @pubsta: the station
6239  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6240  *
6241  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6242  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6243  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6244  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6245  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6246  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6247  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6248  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6249  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6250  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6251  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6252  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6253  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6254  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6255  */
6256 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6257 
6258 /**
6259  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6260  * @pubsta: the station
6261  *
6262  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6263  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6264  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6265  *
6266  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6267  * there is no need to call this function.
6268  */
6269 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6270 
6271 /**
6272  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6273  *
6274  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6275  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6276  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6277  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6278  *
6279  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6280  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6281  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6282  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6283  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6284  * attempts.
6285  *
6286  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6287  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6288  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6289  * them to 0.
6290  *
6291  * @pubsta: the station
6292  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6293  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6294  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6295  */
6296 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6297 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6298 
6299 /**
6300  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6301  *
6302  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6303  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6304  *
6305  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6306  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6307  */
6308 bool
6309 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6310 
6311 /**
6312  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6313  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6314  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6315  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6316  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6317  *
6318  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6319  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6320  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6321  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6322  * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6323  * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6324  *
6325  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6326  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6327  * set_key callback.
6328  */
6329 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6330 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6331 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6332 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6333 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6334 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6335 				      void *data),
6336 			 void *iter_data);
6337 
6338 /**
6339  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6340  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6341  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6342  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6343  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6344  *
6345  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6346  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6347  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6348  * in removal process will be skipped.
6349  *
6350  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6351  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6352  */
6353 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6354 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6355 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6356 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6357 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6358 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6359 					  void *data),
6360 			     void *iter_data);
6361 
6362 /**
6363  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6364  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6365  * @iter: iterator function
6366  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6367  *
6368  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6369  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6370  * places while calling into the driver.
6371  *
6372  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6373  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6374  * removed.
6375  *
6376  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6377  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6378  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6379  * or not.
6380  */
6381 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6382 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6383 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6384 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6385 		     void *data),
6386 	void *iter_data);
6387 
6388 /**
6389  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6390  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6391  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6392  *
6393  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6394  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6395  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6396  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6397  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6398  * %NULL.
6399  *
6400  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6401  */
6402 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6403 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6404 
6405 /**
6406  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6407  *
6408  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6409  *
6410  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6411  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6412  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6413  */
6414 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6415 
6416 /**
6417  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6418  *
6419  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6420  *
6421  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6422  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6423  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6424  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6425  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6426  *
6427  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6428  * without connection recovery attempts.
6429  */
6430 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6431 
6432 /**
6433  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6434  *
6435  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6436  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6437  *
6438  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6439  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6440  */
6441 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6442 
6443 /**
6444  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6445  *
6446  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6447  *
6448  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6449  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6450  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6451  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6452  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6453  *
6454  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6455  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6456  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6457  * disconnect normally later.
6458  *
6459  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6460  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6461  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6462  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6463  */
6464 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6465 
6466 /**
6467  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6468  * hardware restart
6469  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6470  *
6471  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6472  * hardware restart.
6473  */
6474 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6475 
6476 /**
6477  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6478  *	rssi threshold triggered
6479  *
6480  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6481  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6482  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6483  * @gfp: context flags
6484  *
6485  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6486  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6487  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6488  */
6489 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6490 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6491 			       s32 rssi_level,
6492 			       gfp_t gfp);
6493 
6494 /**
6495  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6496  *
6497  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6498  * @gfp: context flags
6499  */
6500 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6501 
6502 /**
6503  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6504  *
6505  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6506  */
6507 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6508 
6509 /**
6510  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6511  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6512  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6513  *
6514  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6515  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6516  */
6517 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6518 
6519 /**
6520  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6521  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6522  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6523  *
6524  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6525  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6526  * a deauth frame in this case.
6527  */
6528 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6529 					 bool block_tx);
6530 
6531 /**
6532  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6533  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6534  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6535  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6536  *
6537  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6538  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6539  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6540  */
6541 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6542 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6543 
6544 /**
6545  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6546  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6547  */
6548 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6549 
6550 /**
6551  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6552  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6553  */
6554 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6555 
6556 /**
6557  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6558  *
6559  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6560  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6561  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6562  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6563  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6564  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6565  *
6566  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6567  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6568  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6569  */
6570 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6571 				  const u8 *addr);
6572 
6573 /**
6574  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6575  * @pubsta: station struct
6576  * @tid: the session's TID
6577  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6578  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6579  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6580  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6581  *
6582  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6583  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6584  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6585  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6586  */
6587 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6588 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6589 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6590 
6591 /**
6592  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6593  *
6594  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6595  * buffer.
6596  *
6597  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6598  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6599  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6600  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6601  */
6602 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6603 
6604 /**
6605  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6606  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6607  * @addr: station mac address
6608  * @tid: the rx tid
6609  */
6610 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6611 				 unsigned int tid);
6612 
6613 /**
6614  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6615  *
6616  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6617  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6618  * reordering.
6619  *
6620  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6621  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6622  *
6623  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6624  * @addr: station mac address
6625  * @tid: the rx tid
6626  */
6627 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6628 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6629 {
6630 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6631 		return;
6632 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6633 }
6634 
6635 /**
6636  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6637  *
6638  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6639  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6640  * reordering.
6641  *
6642  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6643  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6644  *
6645  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6646  * @addr: station mac address
6647  * @tid: the rx tid
6648  */
6649 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6650 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6651 {
6652 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6653 		return;
6654 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6655 }
6656 
6657 /**
6658  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6659  *
6660  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6661  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6662  *
6663  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6664  *
6665  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6666  * @addr: station mac address
6667  * @tid: the rx tid
6668  */
6669 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6670 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6671 
6672 /* Rate control API */
6673 
6674 /**
6675  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6676  *
6677  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6678  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6679  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6680  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6681  *	to be filled in
6682  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6683  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6684  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6685  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6686  *	RTS threshold
6687  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6688  *	if the selected rate supports it
6689  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6690  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6691  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6692  */
6693 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6694 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6695 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6696 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6697 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6698 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6699 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6700 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6701 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6702 	bool bss;
6703 };
6704 
6705 /**
6706  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6707  */
6708 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6709 	/**
6710 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6711 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6712 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6713 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6714 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6715 	 */
6716 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6717 	/**
6718 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6719 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6720 	 */
6721 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6722 };
6723 
6724 struct rate_control_ops {
6725 	unsigned long capa;
6726 	const char *name;
6727 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6728 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6729 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6730 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6731 
6732 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6733 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6734 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6735 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6736 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6737 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6738 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6739 			    u32 changed);
6740 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6741 			 void *priv_sta);
6742 
6743 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6744 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6745 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6746 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6747 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6748 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6749 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6750 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6751 
6752 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6753 				struct dentry *dir);
6754 
6755 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6756 };
6757 
6758 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6759 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6760 				 int index)
6761 {
6762 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6763 }
6764 
6765 static inline s8
6766 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6767 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6768 {
6769 	int i;
6770 
6771 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6772 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6773 			return i;
6774 
6775 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6776 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6777 
6778 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6779 	return 0;
6780 }
6781 
6782 static inline
6783 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6784 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6785 {
6786 	unsigned int i;
6787 
6788 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6789 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6790 			return true;
6791 	return false;
6792 }
6793 
6794 /**
6795  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6796  *
6797  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6798  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6799  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6800  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6801  *
6802  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6803  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6804  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6805  */
6806 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6807 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6808 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6809 
6810 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6811 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6812 
6813 static inline bool
6814 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6815 {
6816 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6817 }
6818 
6819 static inline bool
6820 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6821 {
6822 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6823 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6824 }
6825 
6826 static inline bool
6827 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6828 {
6829 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6830 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6831 }
6832 
6833 static inline bool
6834 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6835 {
6836 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6837 }
6838 
6839 static inline bool
6840 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6841 {
6842 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6843 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6844 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6845 }
6846 
6847 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6848 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6849 {
6850 	if (p2p) {
6851 		switch (type) {
6852 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6853 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6854 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6855 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6856 		default:
6857 			break;
6858 		}
6859 	}
6860 	return type;
6861 }
6862 
6863 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6864 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6865 {
6866 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6867 }
6868 
6869 /**
6870  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6871  *
6872  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6873  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6874  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6875  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6876  *
6877  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6878  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6879  * matching GroupId management frame.
6880  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6881  */
6882 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6883 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6884 
6885 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6886 				   int rssi_min_thold,
6887 				   int rssi_max_thold);
6888 
6889 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6890 
6891 /**
6892  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6893  *
6894  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6895  *
6896  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6897  *
6898  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6899  * applicable.
6900  */
6901 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6902 
6903 /**
6904  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6905  * @vif: virtual interface
6906  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6907  * @gfp: allocation flags
6908  *
6909  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6910  */
6911 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6912 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6913 				    gfp_t gfp);
6914 
6915 /**
6916  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6917  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6918  * @vif: virtual interface
6919  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6920  * @band: the band to transmit on
6921  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6922  *
6923  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6924  */
6925 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6926 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6927 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6928 
6929 /**
6930  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6931  *				 of injected frames.
6932  *
6933  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6934  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6935  * of the skb before calling this function.
6936  *
6937  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6938  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6939  */
6940 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6941 				 struct net_device *dev);
6942 
6943 /**
6944  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6945  *
6946  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6947  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6948  *
6949  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6950  *
6951  * private:
6952  *
6953  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6954  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6955  */
6956 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6957 	u32 next_tsf;
6958 	bool has_next_tsf;
6959 
6960 	u8 absent;
6961 
6962 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6963 	struct {
6964 		u32 start;
6965 		u32 duration;
6966 		u32 interval;
6967 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6968 };
6969 
6970 /**
6971  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6972  *
6973  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6974  * @data: NoA tracking data
6975  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6976  *
6977  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6978  */
6979 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6980 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6981 
6982 /**
6983  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6984  *
6985  * @data: NoA tracking data
6986  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6987  */
6988 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6989 
6990 /**
6991  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6992  * @vif: virtual interface
6993  * @peer: the peer's destination address
6994  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6995  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6996  * @gfp: allocation flags
6997  *
6998  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6999  */
7000 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7001 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7002 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7003 
7004 /**
7005  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7006  *
7007  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7008  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7009  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7010  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7011  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7012  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7013  *
7014  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7015  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7016  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7017  *
7018  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7019  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7020  *
7021  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7022  */
7023 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7024 
7025 /**
7026  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7027  *
7028  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7029  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7030  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7031  *
7032  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7033  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7034  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7035  *
7036  * @sta: the station
7037  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7038  */
7039 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7040 
7041 /**
7042  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7043  *
7044  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7045  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7046  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7047  *
7048  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7049  *
7050  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7051  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7052  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7053  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7054  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7055  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7056  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7057  *
7058  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7059  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7060  */
7061 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7062 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7063 
7064 /**
7065  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7066  * (in process context)
7067  *
7068  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7069  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7070  *
7071  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7072  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7073  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7074  */
7075 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7076 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7077 {
7078 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7079 
7080 	local_bh_disable();
7081 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7082 	local_bh_enable();
7083 
7084 	return skb;
7085 }
7086 
7087 /**
7088  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7089  *
7090  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7091  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7092  *
7093  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7094  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7095  */
7096 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7097 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7098 
7099 /**
7100  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7101  *
7102  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7103  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7104  *
7105  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7106  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7107  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7108  */
7109 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7110 
7111 /**
7112  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7113  *
7114  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7115  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7116  *
7117  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7118  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7119  */
7120 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7121 
7122 /* (deprecated) */
7123 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7124 {
7125 }
7126 
7127 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7128 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7129 
7130 /**
7131  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7132  *
7133  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7134  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7135  *
7136  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7137  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7138  *
7139  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7140  * this TXQ internally.
7141  */
7142 static inline void
7143 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7144 {
7145 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7146 }
7147 
7148 /**
7149  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7150  *
7151  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7152  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7153  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7154  *
7155  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7156  * internally.
7157  */
7158 static inline void
7159 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7160 		     bool force)
7161 {
7162 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7163 }
7164 
7165 /**
7166  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7167  *
7168  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7169  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7170  * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7171  * next_txq().
7172  *
7173  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7174  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7175  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7176  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7177  * again.
7178  *
7179  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7180  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7181  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7182  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7183  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7184  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7185  *
7186  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7187  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7188  */
7189 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7190 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7191 
7192 /**
7193  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7194  *
7195  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7196  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7197  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7198  *
7199  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7200  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7201  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7202  */
7203 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7204 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7205 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7206 
7207 /**
7208  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7209  *
7210  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7211  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7212  *
7213  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7214  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7215  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7216  * @gfp: allocation flags
7217  */
7218 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7219 				   u8 inst_id,
7220 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7221 				   gfp_t gfp);
7222 
7223 /**
7224  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7225  *
7226  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7227  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7228  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7229  *
7230  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7231  * @match: match event information
7232  * @gfp: allocation flags
7233  */
7234 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7235 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7236 			      gfp_t gfp);
7237 
7238 /**
7239  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7240  *
7241  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7242  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7243  *
7244  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7245  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7246  *          information.
7247  * @len: frame length in bytes
7248  */
7249 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7250 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7251 			      int len);
7252 
7253 /**
7254  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7255  *
7256  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7257  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7258  *
7259  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7260  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7261  * @len: frame length in bytes
7262  */
7263 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7264 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7265 			      int len);
7266 /**
7267  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7268  *
7269  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7270  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7271  * hardware or firmware.
7272  *
7273  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7274  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7275  */
7276 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7277 
7278 /**
7279  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7280  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7281  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7282  *
7283  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7284  *
7285  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7286  */
7287 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7288 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7289 
7290 /**
7291  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7292  *	probe response template.
7293  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7294  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7295  *
7296  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7297  *
7298  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7299  */
7300 struct sk_buff *
7301 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7302 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7303 
7304 /**
7305  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7306  * collision.
7307  *
7308  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7309  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7310  *	aware of.
7311  * @gfp: allocation flags
7312  */
7313 void
7314 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7315 				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7316 
7317 /**
7318  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7319  *
7320  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7321  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7322  *
7323  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7324  */
7325 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7326 {
7327 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7328 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7329 
7330 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7331 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7332 }
7333 
7334 /**
7335  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7336  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7337  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7338  *
7339  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7340  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7341  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7342  *
7343  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7344  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7345  * a sequence of calls like
7346  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7347  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7348  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7349  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7350  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7351  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7352  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7353  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7354  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7355  *
7356  * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7357  *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7358  *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7359  */
7360 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7361 
7362 /**
7363  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7364  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7365  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7366  *
7367  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7368  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7369  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7370  * completed after it returns.
7371  */
7372 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7373 				      u16 active_links);
7374 
7375 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7376